blob: a1a9438d0048640fe671fc377a6edbf838676376 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000686 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000688 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
689 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000690 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000691}
692
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
695 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
696 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
697 // language-specific address space.
698 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
699 1, // opencl_global
700 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000701 3, // opencl_constant
702 4, // cuda_device
703 5, // cuda_constant
704 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000705 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000706 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000707 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000708 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000709 }
710}
711
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000712static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
713 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
714 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000715 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
716 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
717 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
718 return true;
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
720 return false;
721 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000722 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723}
724
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000725ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000726 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000727 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
729 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
730 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000732 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr),
733 Int128Decl(nullptr), UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
734 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
735 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr),
739 jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
741 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000742 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
743 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000744 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000745 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000746 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
747 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
748 DeclarationNames(*this),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000749 ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000750 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000751 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000752 LastSDM(nullptr, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000753{
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000754 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
755}
756
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000757ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000758 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
759
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000760 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
761 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
762 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000763
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
765 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
766 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
767 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
768 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000791 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000792}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000793
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000794void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
795 if (!AllParents) return;
796 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
797 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
798 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
799 } else {
800 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
801 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
802 }
803 }
804}
805
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000806void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000807 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000808}
809
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000810void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000811ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
812 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000813}
814
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000815void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000816 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
817 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000818
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000819 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000820#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000821#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
822#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
823 0 // Extra
824 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
827 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000828 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000829 }
830
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000831 unsigned Idx = 0;
832 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
833#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
834 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000835 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
836 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000837 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
838 ++Idx;
839#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
840#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000841
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000842 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
843
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000844 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
846 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
847 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
848 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
849 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
850 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000851 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000852 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
853 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
854 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
855 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
856 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
857 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
861 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
862 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
863 << NumImplicitDestructors
864 << " implicit destructors created\n";
865
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000866 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000867 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000868 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
869 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000871 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000872}
873
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000874RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
875 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000876 SourceLocation Loc;
877 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000878 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
879 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
880 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000881 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000882 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
883 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000884 NewDecl->setImplicit();
885 return NewDecl;
886}
887
888TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
889 StringRef Name) const {
890 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
891 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
892 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
893 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
894 NewDecl->setImplicit();
895 return NewDecl;
896}
897
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000898TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000899 if (!Int128Decl)
900 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000901 return Int128Decl;
902}
903
904TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000905 if (!UInt128Decl)
906 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000907 return UInt128Decl;
908}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000909
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000910TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000911 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000912 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000913 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000914
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000915 return Float128StubDecl;
916}
917
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000918void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000919 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000920 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000921 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000922}
923
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000924void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
925 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
926 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000927 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000928
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000929 this->Target = &Target;
930
931 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
932 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000933 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000934
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000935 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000936 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000937
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000938 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000939 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000940 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000941 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000942 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
943 else
944 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000945 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000946 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
947 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
948 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
949 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
950 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000951
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000952 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000953 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
954 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
955 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
956 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
957 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000958
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000959 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000960 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
961 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
962 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000963
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000964 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
965 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
966 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
967
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000968 // C++ 3.9.1p5
969 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
970 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
971 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
972 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
973 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
974 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
975 else {
976 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
977 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
978 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000979
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000980 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
981
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000982 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
983 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
984 else // C99
985 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
986
987 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
988 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
989 else // C99
990 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
991
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000992 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
993 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
994 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
995 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
996 // expressions.
997 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000998
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000999 // Placeholder type for functions.
1000 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1001
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001002 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1003 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1004
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001005 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1006 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1007
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001008 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1009 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1010
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001011 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1012 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1013
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001014 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1015 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1016
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001017 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001018 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1019 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1020 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001021
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001022 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001023 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1024 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001025 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001026
1027 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1028 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1029 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1030 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1031 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1032 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1033 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001034
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001035 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001036 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001037 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001038
1039 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001040 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1041 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001042
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001043 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001044
1045 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001046
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001047 // void * type
1048 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001049
1050 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1051 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001052
1053 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1054 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001055
1056 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1057 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001058}
1059
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001060DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001061 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1062}
1063
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001064AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1065 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1066 if (!Result) {
1067 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1068 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1069 }
1070
1071 return *Result;
1072}
1073
1074/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1075void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1076 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1077 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1078 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1079 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1080 }
1081}
1082
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001083// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001084MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001085ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001086 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001087 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1088 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1089}
1090
1091ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1092ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1093 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1094 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1095 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1096 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001097
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001098 return Pos->second;
1099}
1100
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001101void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001102ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001103 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1104 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001105 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1106 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001107 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1108 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1109}
1110
1111void
1112ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1113 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1114 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1115 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1116 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001117}
1118
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001119FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1120 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1121 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001123 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1124 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001125 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001126
1127 return Pos->second;
1128}
1129
1130void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1131 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1132 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1133 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001134 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001135}
1136
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001137NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001138ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001139 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001140 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1141 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001142 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001144 return Pos->second;
1145}
1146
1147void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001148ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1149 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1150 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1151 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1152 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1153 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1154 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1155}
1156
1157UsingShadowDecl *
1158ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1159 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1160 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1161 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001162 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001163
1164 return Pos->second;
1165}
1166
1167void
1168ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1169 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1170 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1171 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001172}
1173
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001174FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1175 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1176 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1177 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001178 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001179
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001180 return Pos->second;
1181}
1182
1183void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1184 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1185 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1186 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1187 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1188 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001189
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001190 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1191}
1192
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001193ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1194ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1195 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001196 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001197 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001198 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001199
1200 return Pos->second.begin();
1201}
1202
1203ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1204ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1205 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001206 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001207 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001208 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001209
1210 return Pos->second.end();
1211}
1212
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001213unsigned
1214ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1215 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001216 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001217 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1218 return 0;
1219
1220 return Pos->second.size();
1221}
1222
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001223void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1224 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001225 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001226 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1227}
1228
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001229void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1230 const NamedDecl *D,
1231 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001232 assert(D);
1233
1234 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001235 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1236 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001237 return;
1238 }
1239
1240 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1241 if (!Method)
1242 return;
1243
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001244 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1245 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001246 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001247}
1248
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001249void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1250 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1251 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1252 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1253 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1254 LastLocalImport = Import;
1255 return;
1256 }
1257
1258 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1259 LastLocalImport = Import;
1260}
1261
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001262//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1263// Type Sizing and Analysis
1264//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001265
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001266/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1267/// scalar floating point type.
1268const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001269 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001270 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1271 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001272 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001273 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001274 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1275 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1276 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001277 }
1278}
1279
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001280CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001281 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001282
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001283 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1284 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1285 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001286
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001287 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1288 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1289 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1290 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001291 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001292 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1293 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1294 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1295 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1296 } else {
1297 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1298 }
1299 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001300 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1301 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1302 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1303 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001304
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001305 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1306 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001307 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001308 // do nothing
1309
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001310 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001311 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001312 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001313 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001314 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1315 else
1316 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1317 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001318 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1319 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001320 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1321 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001322 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001323 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1324 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001325 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1326 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1327 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1328 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1329 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1330 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001331 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001332 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1334 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1335 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1336 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001337 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001338
1339 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1340 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1341 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1342 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1343 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001344 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1345 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1346 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1347 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1348 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001349
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001350 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1351 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001352
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001353 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1354 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1355 if (Offset > 0) {
1356 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1357 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1358 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1359 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1360 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1361 }
1362
1363 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001364 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001365 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001366 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001367
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001368 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001369}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001370
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001371// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1372// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1373// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1374// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1375std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1376ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1377 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1378
1379 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1380 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1381 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1383 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1384 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1385 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 return sizeAndAlign;
1390}
1391
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001392/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1393/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1394std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1395static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1396 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1397 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1398 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1399 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001400 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1401 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001402 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1403 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1404 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001405 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1406 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1407 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001408 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1409 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1410}
1411
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001412std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001413ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001414 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1415 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001416 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001417 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1418 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001419}
1420
1421std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001422ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001423 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1424}
1425
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001426std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1427 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1428 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1429 return it->second;
1430
1431 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1432 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1433 return Info;
1434}
1435
1436/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1437/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001438///
1439/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1440/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1441/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001442std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001443ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5b9a3d52009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001444 uint64_t Width=0;
1445 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001446 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001447#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1448#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001449#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001450#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001451#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1452 case Type::Class: \
1453 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1454 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001455#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001456 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001457
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001458 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1459 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001460 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1461 Width = 0;
1462 Align = 32;
1463 break;
1464
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001465 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001466 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001467 Width = 0;
1468 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1469 break;
1470
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001471 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001472 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001473
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001474 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001475 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001476 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1477 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001478 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001479 Align = EltInfo.second;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001480 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1481 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1482 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001483 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001484 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001485 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001486 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001487 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1488 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1489 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001490 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001491 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1492 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001493 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001494 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1495 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1496 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001497 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1498 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1499 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1500 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001501 break;
1502 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001503
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001504 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001505 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001506 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001507 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001508 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1509 Width = 0;
1510 Align = 8;
1511 break;
1512
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001513 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001514 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1515 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001516 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001517 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1518 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1519 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001520 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001521 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1522 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001523 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001524 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1525 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001526 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1527 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001528 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001529 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001530 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1531 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001532 break;
1533 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001534 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1535 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001536 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001537 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001538 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1540 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001541 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001542 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001543 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001544 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1545 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001546 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001547 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001548 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001549 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1550 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001551 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001552 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001553 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001554 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1555 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001556 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001557 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1558 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1559 Width = 128;
1560 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1561 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001562 case BuiltinType::Half:
1563 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1564 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1565 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001566 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001567 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1568 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001569 break;
1570 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001571 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1572 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001573 break;
1574 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001575 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1576 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001577 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001578 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001579 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1580 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001581 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001582 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1583 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1584 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001585 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1586 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001587 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001588 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1589 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1590 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1591 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1592 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001593 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001594 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1595 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1596 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1597 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1598 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1599 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1600 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1601 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1602 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1603 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001604 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001605 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001606 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001607 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1608 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001609 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001610 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001611 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1612 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001613 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1614 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001615 break;
1616 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001617 case Type::LValueReference:
1618 case Type::RValueReference: {
1619 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1620 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001621 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1622 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001623 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1624 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001625 break;
1626 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001627 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001628 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001629 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1630 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001631 break;
1632 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001633 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001634 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001635 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001636 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001637 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001638 case Type::Complex: {
1639 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1640 // size.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001641 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001642 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001643 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001644 Align = EltInfo.second;
1645 break;
1646 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001647 case Type::ObjCObject:
1648 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001649 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001650 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001651 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001652 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001653 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001654 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001655 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001656 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001657 break;
1658 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001659 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001660 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001661 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1662
1663 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001664 Width = 8;
1665 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001666 break;
1667 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001668
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001669 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001670 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1671
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001672 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001673 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001674 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001675 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001676 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001677 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001678
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001679 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001680 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1681 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001682
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001683 case Type::Auto: {
1684 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001685 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1686 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001687 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001688 }
1689
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001690 case Type::Paren:
1691 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1692
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001693 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001694 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001695 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1696 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001697 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1698 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1699 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1700 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1701 Align = AttrAlign;
1702 else
1703 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001704 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001705 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001706 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001707
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001708 case Type::Elaborated:
1709 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001710
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001711 case Type::Attributed:
1712 return getTypeInfo(
1713 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1714
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001715 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001716 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001717 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1718 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1719 Width = Info.first;
1720 Align = Info.second;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001721
1722 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1723 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1724 // favorable to atomic operations:
1725 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1726 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1727 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1728 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1729
1730 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001731 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1732 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001733 }
1734
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001735 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001736
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001737 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001738 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001739}
1740
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001741/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1742CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1743 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1744}
1745
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001746/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1747int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1748 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1749}
1750
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001751/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1752/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001753CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001754 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001755}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001756CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001757 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001758}
1759
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001760/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001761/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001762CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001763 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001764}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001765CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001766 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001767}
1768
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001769/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1770/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1771/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1772/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001773unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001774 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001775
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001776 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1777 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1778
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001779 const TypedefType *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
1780
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001781 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
Richard Smithd7e1fe42014-06-10 23:43:44 +00001782 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001783 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001784 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1785 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001786 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1787 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001788 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1789 // typedef declaration.
1790 if (!TT || !TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1791 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001792
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001793 return ABIAlign;
1794}
1795
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001796/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1797/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1798unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1799 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1800}
1801
1802/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1803/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1804CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1805 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1806}
1807
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001808/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1809/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1810/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1811/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1812/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001813///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001814void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1815 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001816 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001817 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1818 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1819 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001820 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1821 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001822 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001823 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001824 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001825 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1826 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1827 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001828}
1829
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001830/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1831/// those inherited by it.
1832void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001833 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001834 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001835 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1836 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001837 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001838 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001839 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1840 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1841 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001842 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001843 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001844
1845 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001846 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1847 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001848
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001849 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1850 while (SD) {
1851 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1852 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1853 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001854 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001855 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001856 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001857 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1858 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001859 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001860 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001861 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001862 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001863 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1864 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001865 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001866 }
1867}
1868
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001869unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001870 unsigned count = 0;
1871 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001872 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001873 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001874
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001875 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1876 // includes synthesized ivars.
1877 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001878 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1879
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001880 return count;
1881}
1882
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001883bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1884 if (!E)
1885 return false;
1886
1887 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1888 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1889
1890 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1891 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1892 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1893 return true;
1894
1895 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1896 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1897
1898 return false;
1899}
1900
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001901/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1902ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1903 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1904 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1905 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1906 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001907 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001908}
1909/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1910ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1911 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1912 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1913 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1914 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001915 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001916}
1917
1918/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1919void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1920 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1921 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1922 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1923}
1924/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1925void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1926 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1927 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1928 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1929}
1930
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001931const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1932 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1933 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1934 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001935 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001936 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1937 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001938 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001939 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1940 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001941 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1942
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001943 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001944}
1945
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001946/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1947/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001948Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001949 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1950 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1951 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001952 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001953 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001954 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001955}
1956
1957/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1958void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1959 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001960 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1961 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001962 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1963}
1964
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001965TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001966 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001967 if (!DataSize)
1968 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1969 else
1970 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001971 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001972
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001973 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1974 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1975 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1976 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001977}
1978
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001979TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001980 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001981 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001982 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001983 return DI;
1984}
1985
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001986const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001987ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001988 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001989}
1990
1991const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001992ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1993 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001994 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1995}
1996
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001997//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1998// Type creation/memoization methods
1999//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2000
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002001QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002002ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2003 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2004 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002005
2006 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2007 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002008 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002009 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002010 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2011 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2012 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002013 }
2014
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002015 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2016 QualType canon;
2017 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2018 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002019 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2020 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002021
2022 // Re-find the insert position.
2023 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2024 }
2025
2026 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2027 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2028 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002029}
2030
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002031QualType
2032ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002033 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2034 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002035 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002036
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002037 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2038 // into one ExtQuals node.
2039 QualifierCollector Quals;
2040 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002041
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002042 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2043 // another one.
2044 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2045 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2046 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002048 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002049}
2050
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002051QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002052 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002053 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002054 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002055 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002056
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002057 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2058 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002059 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002060 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2061 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2062 }
2063 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002064
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002065 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2066 // into one ExtQuals node.
2067 QualifierCollector Quals;
2068 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002069
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002070 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2071 // another one.
2072 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2073 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2074 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002075
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002076 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002077}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002078
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002079const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2080 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2081 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2082 return T;
2083
2084 QualType Result;
2085 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002086 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002087 } else {
2088 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2089 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2090 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002091 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002092 }
2093
2094 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2095}
2096
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002097void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2098 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002099 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2100 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002101 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2102 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002103 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002104 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2105 FD = Next;
2106 else
2107 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002108 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002109 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2110 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002111}
2112
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002113/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2114/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002115QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002116 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2117 // structure.
2118 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2119 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002120
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002121 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002122 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2123 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002124
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002125 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2126 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2127 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002128 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002129 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002131 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2132 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002133 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002134 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002135 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002136 Types.push_back(New);
2137 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2138 return QualType(New, 0);
2139}
2140
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002141/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2142/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002143QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002144 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2145 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002146 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002147 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002149 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002150 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002151 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002153 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2154 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002155 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002156 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002157 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002159 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2160 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002161 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002162 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002163 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002164 Types.push_back(New);
2165 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002166 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002167}
2168
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002169QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2170 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2171 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002172 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002173 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2174 if (AT)
2175 return QualType(AT, 0);
2176
2177 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2178
2179 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2180 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002181 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002182
2183 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2184 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2185 Types.push_back(AT);
2186 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2187 return QualType(AT, 0);
2188}
2189
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002190QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2191 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2192
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002193 QualType Decayed;
2194
2195 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2196 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2197 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2198 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2199 // the array type derivation.
2200 if (T->isArrayType())
2201 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2202
2203 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2204 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2205 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2206 // in 6.3.2.1.
2207 if (T->isFunctionType())
2208 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2209
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002210 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2211 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002212 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002213 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2214 if (AT)
2215 return QualType(AT, 0);
2216
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002217 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2218
2219 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002220 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002221 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002222
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002223 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2224 Types.push_back(AT);
2225 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2226 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002227}
2228
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002229/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002230/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002231QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002232 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2233 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002234 // structure.
2235 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2236 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002237
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002238 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002239 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2240 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2241 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242
2243 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002244 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2245 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002246 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002247 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002248
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002249 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2250 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2251 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002252 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002253 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002254 BlockPointerType *New
2255 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002256 Types.push_back(New);
2257 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2258 return QualType(New, 0);
2259}
2260
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002261/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2262/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002263QualType
2264ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002265 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2266 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2267
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002268 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2269 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002271 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002272
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002273 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002274 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2275 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002276 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002277
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002278 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2279
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002280 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2281 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2282 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002283 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2284 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2285 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002286
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002287 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002288 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2289 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002290 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002291 }
2292
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002293 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002294 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2295 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002296 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002297 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002298
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002299 return QualType(New, 0);
2300}
2301
2302/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2303/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002304QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002305 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2306 // structure.
2307 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002308 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002309
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002310 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002311 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2312 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2313 return QualType(RT, 0);
2314
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002315 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2316
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002317 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2318 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2319 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002320 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2321 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2322 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002323
2324 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2325 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2326 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002327 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002328 }
2329
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002330 RValueReferenceType *New
2331 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002332 Types.push_back(New);
2333 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002334 return QualType(New, 0);
2335}
2336
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002337/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2338/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002339QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002340 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2341 // structure.
2342 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2343 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2344
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002345 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002346 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2347 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2348 return QualType(PT, 0);
2349
2350 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2351 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2352 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002353 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002354 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2355
2356 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2357 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2358 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002359 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002360 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002361 MemberPointerType *New
2362 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002363 Types.push_back(New);
2364 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2365 return QualType(New, 0);
2366}
2367
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002369/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002370QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002371 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002372 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002373 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002374 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2375 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002376 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2377
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002378 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2379 // the target.
2380 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002381 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002382 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002383
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002384 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002385 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002387 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002388 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002389 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002390 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002391
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002392 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2393 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2394 QualType Canon;
2395 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2396 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002397 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002398 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002399 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002400
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002401 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002402 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002403 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002404 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002405 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002407 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002408 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002409 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002410 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002411 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002412}
2413
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002414/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2415/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2416/// sizes replaced with [*].
2417QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2418 // Vastly most common case.
2419 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002420
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002421 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002422
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002423 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002424 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002425 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2426#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2427#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2428#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2429#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2430 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2431
2432 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2433 case Type::Builtin:
2434 case Type::Complex:
2435 case Type::Vector:
2436 case Type::ExtVector:
2437 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2438 case Type::ObjCObject:
2439 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2440 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2441 case Type::Record:
2442 case Type::Enum:
2443 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2444 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2445 case Type::TypeOf:
2446 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002447 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002448 case Type::DependentName:
2449 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2450 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2451 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2452 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2453 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002454 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002455 case Type::PackExpansion:
2456 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2457
2458 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2459 // further decay.
2460 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2461 case Type::FunctionProto:
2462 case Type::BlockPointer:
2463 case Type::MemberPointer:
2464 return type;
2465
2466 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2467 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2468 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2469 // optimizations available here.
2470 case Type::Pointer:
2471 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2472 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2473 break;
2474
2475 case Type::LValueReference: {
2476 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2477 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2478 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2479 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2480 break;
2481 }
2482
2483 case Type::RValueReference: {
2484 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2485 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2486 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2487 break;
2488 }
2489
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002490 case Type::Atomic: {
2491 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2492 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2493 break;
2494 }
2495
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002496 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2497 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2498 result = getConstantArrayType(
2499 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2500 cat->getSize(),
2501 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2502 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2503 break;
2504 }
2505
2506 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2507 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2508 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2509 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2510 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2511 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2512 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2513 dat->getBracketsRange());
2514 break;
2515 }
2516
2517 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2518 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2519 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2520 result = getVariableArrayType(
2521 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002522 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002523 ArrayType::Normal,
2524 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2525 SourceRange());
2526 break;
2527 }
2528
2529 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2530 case Type::VariableArray: {
2531 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2532 result = getVariableArrayType(
2533 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002534 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002535 ArrayType::Star,
2536 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2537 vat->getBracketsRange());
2538 break;
2539 }
2540 }
2541
2542 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002543 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002544}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002545
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002546/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2547/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002548QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2549 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002550 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002551 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002552 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002553 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2554 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002555 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002556
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002557 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2558 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2559 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002560 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002561 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002562 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002563 }
2564
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002565 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002566 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002567
2568 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2569 Types.push_back(New);
2570 return QualType(New, 0);
2571}
2572
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002573/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2574/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002575/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002576QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2577 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002578 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002579 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2580 SourceRange brackets) const {
2581 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2582 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002583 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2584
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002585 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2586 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2587 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2588 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2589 if (!numElements) {
2590 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2591 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2592 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2593 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2594 brackets);
2595 Types.push_back(newType);
2596 return QualType(newType, 0);
2597 }
2598
2599 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2600 // also build a canonical type.
2601
2602 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2603
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002604 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002605 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002606 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002607 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002608 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002609
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002610 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2611 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2612 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002613
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002614 // If we don't have one, build one.
2615 if (!canonTy) {
2616 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002617 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002618 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2619 brackets);
2620 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2621 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002622 }
2623
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002624 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2625 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002626 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002627
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002628 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2629 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002630 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002631 return canon;
2632
2633 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2634 // of the element type.
2635 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2636 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2637 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2638 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2639 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2640 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002641}
2642
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002643QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002644 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002645 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002646 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002647 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002648
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002649 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002650 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2651 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2652 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002653
2654 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002655 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2656 // qualifiers off the element type.
2657 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002658
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002659 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2660 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002661 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002662 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002663 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002664
2665 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002666 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2667 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2668 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002669 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002670
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002671 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2672 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002673
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002674 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2675 Types.push_back(newType);
2676 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002677}
2678
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002679/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2680/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002681QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002682 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002683 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002684
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002685 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2686 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002687 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002688
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002689 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002690 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2691 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2692
2693 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2694 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2695 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002696 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002697 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002698
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002699 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2700 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002701 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002702 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002703 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002704 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002705 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2706 Types.push_back(New);
2707 return QualType(New, 0);
2708}
2709
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002710/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002711/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002712QualType
2713ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002714 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002715
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002716 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2717 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002718 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002719 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002720 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002721 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2722 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2723
2724 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2725 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2726 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002727 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002728 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002729
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002730 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2731 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002732 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002733 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002734 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2735 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002736 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2737 Types.push_back(New);
2738 return QualType(New, 0);
2739}
2740
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002741QualType
2742ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2743 Expr *SizeExpr,
2744 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002745 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002746 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002747 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002748
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002749 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002750 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2751 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2752 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2753 if (Canon) {
2754 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2755 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002756 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2757 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2758 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002759 } else {
2760 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2761 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002762 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2763 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2764 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002765
2766 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2767 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2768 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2769 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002770 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2771 } else {
2772 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2773 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002774 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2775 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002776 }
2777 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002778
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002779 Types.push_back(New);
2780 return QualType(New, 0);
2781}
2782
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002783/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002784///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002785QualType
2786ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2787 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002788 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2789
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002790 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2791 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002792 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002793 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002794
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002795 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002796 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002797 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002798 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002799
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002800 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002801 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2802 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002803
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002804 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002805 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2806 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002807 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002808 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002809
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002810 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002811 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002812 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002813 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002814 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002815 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002816}
2817
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002818/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2819static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2820 return T.isCanonical() &&
2821 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2822 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2823}
2824
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002825QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002826ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002827 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002828 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2829
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002830 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2831 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002832 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002833 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2834 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002835
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002836 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002837 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002838 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002839 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002840
2841 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002842 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002843 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002844 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002845 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002846 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002847 isCanonical = false;
2848
2849 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002850 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002851 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002852 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002853 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002854 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2855 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002856 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002857
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002858 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002859 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002860 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2861 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002862
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002863 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2864 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2865 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2866 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2867 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2868 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2869 }
2870
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002871 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002872
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002873 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002874 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2875 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002876 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002877 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002878
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002879 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2880 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2881 // - parameter types
2882 // - exception types
2883 // - consumed-arguments flags
2884 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002885 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2886 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002887 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002888 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002889 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002890 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002891 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002892 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002893 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002894 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002895 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2896 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002897 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002898 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002899 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2900
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002901 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002902 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002903 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002904 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002905 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002906 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002907}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002908
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002909#ifndef NDEBUG
2910static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2911 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2912 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2913 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2914 return true;
2915 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2916 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2917 return true;
2918 return false;
2919}
2920#endif
2921
2922/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2923/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2924QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002925 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002926 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2927 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2928 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002929 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002930 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2931 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2932 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2933 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002934 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002935 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002936 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2937 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002938 }
2939 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2940}
2941
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002942/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2943/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002944QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002945 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002946 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002947
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002948 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002949 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002950
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002951 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2952 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2953
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002954 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002955 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002956 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002957 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002958 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002959 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002960 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002961 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002962 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002963 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2964 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2965 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002966 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002967 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002968
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002969 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002970}
2971
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002972/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002973/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002974QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002975ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2976 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002977 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002978
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002979 if (Canonical.isNull())
2980 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002981 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002982 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002983 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2984 Types.push_back(newType);
2985 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002986}
2987
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002988QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002989 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2990
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002991 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002992 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2993 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2994
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002995 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2996 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2997 Types.push_back(newType);
2998 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002999}
3000
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003001QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003002 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3003
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003004 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003005 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3006 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3007
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003008 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3009 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3010 Types.push_back(newType);
3011 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003012}
3013
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003014QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3015 QualType modifiedType,
3016 QualType equivalentType) {
3017 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3018 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3019
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003020 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003021 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3022 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3023
3024 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3025 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3026 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3027
3028 Types.push_back(type);
3029 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3030
3031 return QualType(type, 0);
3032}
3033
3034
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003035/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3036QualType
3037ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003038 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003039 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003040 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3041
3042 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3043 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003044 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003045 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3046 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3047
3048 if (!SubstParm) {
3049 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3050 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3051 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3052 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3053 }
3054
3055 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3056}
3057
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003058/// \brief Retrieve a
3059QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3060 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3061 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3062#ifndef NDEBUG
3063 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
3064 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
3065 P != PEnd; ++P) {
3066 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3067 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3068 }
3069#endif
3070
3071 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3072 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003073 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003074 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3075 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3076 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3077
3078 QualType Canon;
3079 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3080 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3081 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3082 ArgPack);
3083 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3084 }
3085
3086 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3087 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3088 ArgPack);
3089 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3090 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3091 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3092}
3093
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003094/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003095/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003096/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003097QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003098 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003099 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003100 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003101 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003102 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003104 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3105
3106 if (TypeParm)
3107 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003108
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003109 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003110 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003111 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003112
3113 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3114 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3115 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3116 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003117 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003118 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3119 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003120
3121 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3122 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3123
3124 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3125}
3126
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003127TypeSourceInfo *
3128ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3129 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3130 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003131 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003132 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3133 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003134 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003135
3136 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003137 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3138 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003139 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003140 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3141 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3142 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3143 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3144 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3145 return DI;
3146}
3147
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003148QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003149ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003150 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003151 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003152 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3153 "No dependent template names here!");
3154
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003155 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3156
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003157 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003158 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3159 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3160 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3161
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003162 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003163 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003164}
3165
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003166#ifndef NDEBUG
3167static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3168 unsigned NumArgs) {
3169 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3170 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3171 return true;
3172
3173 return true;
3174}
3175#endif
3176
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003177QualType
3178ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003179 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3180 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003181 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003182 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3183 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003184 // Look through qualified template names.
3185 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3186 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003187
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003188 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003189 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3190 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003191 QualType CanonType;
3192 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3193 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3194 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003195 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3196 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3197 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3198 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3199 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003200 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3201 NumArgs);
3202 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003203
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003204 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3205 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3206 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003207 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3208 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003209 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003210 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003211 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003212 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3213 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003214
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003215 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003216 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003217}
3218
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003220ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3221 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003222 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003223 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3224 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003225
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003226 // Look through qualified template names.
3227 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3228 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003229
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003230 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3231 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003232 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003233 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3234 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3235 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3236
3237 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3238 // exists.
3239 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3240 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3241 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3242
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003243 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003244 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3245 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3246
3247 if (!Spec) {
3248 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3249 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3250 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3251 TypeAlignment);
3252 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3253 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003254 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003255 Types.push_back(Spec);
3256 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3257 }
3258
3259 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3260 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3261 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3262}
3263
3264QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003265ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3266 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003267 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003268 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003269 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003270
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003271 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003272 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003273 if (T)
3274 return QualType(T, 0);
3275
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003276 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3277 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3278 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003279 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3280 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003281 (void)CheckT;
3282 }
3283
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003284 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003285 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003286 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003287 return QualType(T, 0);
3288}
3289
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003290QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003291ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003292 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3293 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3294
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003295 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003296 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3297 if (T)
3298 return QualType(T, 0);
3299
3300 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3301 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3302 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3303 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3304 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3305 (void)CheckT;
3306 }
3307
3308 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3309 Types.push_back(T);
3310 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3311 return QualType(T, 0);
3312}
3313
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003314QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3315 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3316 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003317 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003318 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3319 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003320 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3321 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3322 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3323
3324 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3325 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003326 }
3327
3328 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003329 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003330
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003331 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003332 DependentNameType *T
3333 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003334 if (T)
3335 return QualType(T, 0);
3336
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003337 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003338 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003339 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003340 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003341}
3342
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003343QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003344ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3345 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003346 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003347 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003348 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003349 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003350 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003351 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3352 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3353 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3354 ArgCopy.size(),
3355 ArgCopy.data());
3356}
3357
3358QualType
3359ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3360 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3361 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3362 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3363 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003364 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003365 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3366 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003367
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003368 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003369 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3370 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003371
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003372 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003373 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3374 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003375 if (T)
3376 return QualType(T, 0);
3377
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003378 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003379
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003380 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3381 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3382
3383 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003384 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003385 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3386 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3387 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3388 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003389 }
3390
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003391 QualType Canon;
3392 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3393 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3394 Name, NumArgs,
3395 CanonArgs.data());
3396
3397 // Find the insert position again.
3398 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3399 }
3400
3401 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3402 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3403 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003404 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003405 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003406 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003407 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003408 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003409}
3410
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003411QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003412 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003413 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003414 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003415
3416 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3417 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003418 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003419 PackExpansionType *T
3420 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3421 if (T)
3422 return QualType(T, 0);
3423
3424 QualType Canon;
3425 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003426 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3427 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3428 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3429 // parameters.
3430 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003431 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003432
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003433 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3434 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3435 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3436 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003437 }
3438
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003439 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003440 Types.push_back(T);
3441 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003442 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003443}
3444
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003445/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3446/// alphabetically.
3447static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3448 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003449 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003450}
3451
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003452static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003453 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3454 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3455
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003456 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3457 return false;
3458
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003459 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003460 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3461 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003462 return false;
3463 return true;
3464}
3465
3466static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003467 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3468 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003469
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003470 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3471 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3472
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003473 // Canonicalize.
3474 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3475 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3476
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003477 // Remove duplicates.
3478 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3479 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3480}
3481
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003482QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3483 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003484 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003485 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3486 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3487 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3488 return BaseType;
3489
3490 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003491 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003492 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003493 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003494 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3495 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003496
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003497 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3498 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003499 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003500 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3501 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3502 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003503 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003504 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003505 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3506
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003507 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003508 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3509 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003510 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003511 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3512 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003513 }
3514
3515 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003516 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3517 }
3518
3519 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3520 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3521 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3522 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3523 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3524
3525 Types.push_back(T);
3526 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3527 return QualType(T, 0);
3528}
3529
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003530/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3531/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3532/// list.
3533bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3534 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3535 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3536 return false;
3537
3538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3539 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003540 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003541 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3542 return false;
3543 }
3544 return true;
3545 }
3546 return false;
3547}
3548
3549/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3550/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3551/// of protocols.
3552bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3553 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3554 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3555 return false;
3556 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3557 if (!OPT)
3558 return false;
3559 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3560 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003561 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3562 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3563 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3564 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003565 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3566 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3567 bool Conforms = false;
3568 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3569 Conforms = false;
3570 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3571 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3572 Conforms = true;
3573 break;
3574 }
3575 }
3576 if (!Conforms)
3577 break;
3578 }
3579 if (Conforms)
3580 return true;
3581
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003582 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003583 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3584 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003585 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003586 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003587 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003588 break;
3589 }
3590 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003591 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003592 }
3593 return true;
3594}
3595
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003596/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3597/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003598QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003599 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3600 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3601
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003602 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003603 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3604 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3605 return QualType(QT, 0);
3606
3607 // Find the canonical object type.
3608 QualType Canonical;
3609 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3610 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3611
3612 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003613 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3614 }
3615
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003616 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003617 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3618 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3619 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003620
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003621 Types.push_back(QType);
3622 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003623 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003624}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003625
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003626/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3627/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003628QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3629 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003630 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3631 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003632
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003633 if (PrevDecl) {
3634 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3635 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3636 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3637 }
3638
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003639 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3640 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3641 Decl = Def;
3642
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003643 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3644 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3645 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3646 Types.push_back(T);
3647 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003648}
3649
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003650/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3651/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003652/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003653/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003654/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003655QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003656 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003657 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3658 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3659 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003660
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003661 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003662 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3663 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3664 if (Canon) {
3665 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3666 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003667 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003668 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003669 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003670 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003671 Canon
3672 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003673 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3674 toe = Canon;
3675 }
3676 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003677 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003678 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003679 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003680 Types.push_back(toe);
3681 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003682}
3683
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003684/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003685/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003686/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003687/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3688/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003689QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003690 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003691 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003692 Types.push_back(tot);
3693 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003694}
3695
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003696
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003697/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3698/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3699/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3700/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003701QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003702 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003703
3704 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003705 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003706 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3707 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003708 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003709 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3710 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003711
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003712 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003713 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3714 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003715 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003716 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003717 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003718 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003719 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003720 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3721 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003722 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003723 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3724 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003725 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003726 Types.push_back(dt);
3727 return QualType(dt, 0);
3728}
3729
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003730/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3731/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3732QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3733 QualType UnderlyingType,
3734 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3735 const {
3736 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003737 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3738 Kind,
3739 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003740 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003741 Types.push_back(Ty);
3742 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3743}
3744
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003745/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3746/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3747/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3748QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003749 bool IsDependent) const {
3750 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003751 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003752
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003753 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003754 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003755 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003756 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003757 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3758 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003759
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003760 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003761 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003762 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003763 Types.push_back(AT);
3764 if (InsertPos)
3765 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3766 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003767}
3768
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003769/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3770/// the given value type.
3771QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3772 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3773 // structure.
3774 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3775 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3776
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003777 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003778 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3779 return QualType(AT, 0);
3780
3781 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3782 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3783 QualType Canonical;
3784 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3785 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3786
3787 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3788 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003789 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003790 }
3791 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3792 Types.push_back(New);
3793 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3794 return QualType(New, 0);
3795}
3796
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003797/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3798QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3799 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003800 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3801 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003802 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003803 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003804 return AutoDeductTy;
3805}
3806
3807/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3808QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3809 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3810 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3811 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3812 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3813}
3814
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003815/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3816/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003817QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003818 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003819 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3820 // away const? mutable?
3821 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003822}
3823
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3825/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3826/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003827CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003828 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003829}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003830
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003831/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3832CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3833 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3834}
3835
3836/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3837CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3838 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3839}
3840
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003841/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3842/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3843QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3844 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3845 return WCharTy;
3846}
3847
3848/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3849/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3850QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3851 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3852 return UnsignedIntTy;
3853}
3854
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003855QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3856 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3857}
3858
3859QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3860 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3861}
3862
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003863/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003864/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3865QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003866 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003867}
3868
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003869/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3870/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3871QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3872 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3873}
3874
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003875//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3876// Type Operators
3877//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3878
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003879CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003880 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3881 // qualifiers.
3882 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003883 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003884 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003885 QualType Result;
3886 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3887 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3888 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3889 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3890 } else {
3891 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3892 }
3893
3894 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3895}
3896
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003897QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3898 Qualifiers &quals) {
3899 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3900
3901 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3902 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3903 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3904 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3905 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003906 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003907
3908 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003909 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003910 quals = splitType.Quals;
3911 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003912 }
3913
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003914 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3915 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3916 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3917
3918 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3919 // can just use the results in splitType.
3920 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3921 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003922 quals = splitType.Quals;
3923 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003924 }
3925
3926 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3927 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003928 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003929
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003930 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003931 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003932 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3933 }
3934
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003935 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003936 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003937 }
3938
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003939 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003940 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003941 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003942 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3943 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3944 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3945 }
3946
3947 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003948 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003949 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3950 SourceRange());
3951}
3952
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003953/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3954/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3955/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3956/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3957/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3958/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3959/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3960/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3961bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3962 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3963 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3964 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3965 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3966 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3967 return true;
3968 }
3969
3970 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3971 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3972 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3973 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3974 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3975 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3976 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3977 return true;
3978 }
3979
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003980 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003981 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3982 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3983 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3984 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3985 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3986 return true;
3987 }
3988 }
3989
3990 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3991
3992 return false;
3993}
3994
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003995DeclarationNameInfo
3996ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3997 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003998 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3999 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4000 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004001 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004002 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4003 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004004
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004005 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4006 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4007 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4008 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4009 }
4010
4011 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4012 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004013 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004014 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004015 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4016 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004017 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004018 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4019 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4020 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4021 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4022 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4023 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004024 }
4025 }
4026
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004027 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4028 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4029 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4030 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4031 NameLoc);
4032 }
4033
4034 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4035 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4036 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4037 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4038 NameLoc);
4039 }
4040 }
4041
4042 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004043}
4044
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004045TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004046 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4047 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4048 case TemplateName::Template: {
4049 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004050 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004051 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004052 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4053
4054 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004055 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004056 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004057
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004058 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4059 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004060
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004061 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4062 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4063 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4064 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4065 }
4066
4067 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4068 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4069 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4070 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4071 }
4072
4073 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4074 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4075 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4076 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4077 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4078 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4079 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4080 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4081 }
4082 }
4083
4084 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004085}
4086
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004087bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4088 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4089 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4090 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4091}
4092
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004093TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004094ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004095 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4096 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4097 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004098
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004099 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004100 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004101
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004102 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004103 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4104 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004106
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004107 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4108 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4109 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4110
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004111 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4112 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004113
4114 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4115 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4116 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004117 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004118
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004119 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004120 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004121
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004122 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004123 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004124
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004125 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004126 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4127 return Arg;
4128
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004129 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4130 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004131 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004132 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004133 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4134 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4135 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004137 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004138 }
4139 }
4140
4141 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004142 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004143}
4144
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004145NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004146ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004148 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004149
4150 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4151 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4152 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004153 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004154 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4155 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4156
4157 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4158 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4159 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004160 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004161 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4162
4163 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4164 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4165 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004166 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004167 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4168 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004169
4170 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4171 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4172 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004173
4174 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4175 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4176 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4177 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4178 // types, e.g.,
4179 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4180 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004181 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4182 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004183 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004184
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004185 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4186 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4187 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004188 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4189 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004190 }
4191
4192 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4193 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4194 return NNS;
4195 }
4196
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004197 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004198}
4199
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004200
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004201const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004202 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004203 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004204 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4205 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4206 return AT;
4207 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004208
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004209 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004210 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004211 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004212
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004213 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004214 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4215 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004216
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004217 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4218 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004219 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004221 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004222 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004223
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004224 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004225 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004226 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004227 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004228
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004229 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4230 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004231 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004232
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004233 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4234 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4235 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004236 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004237 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4238 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4239 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004240 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004241
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004242 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004243 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4244 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004245 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004246 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004247 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004248 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004249 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004250
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004251 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004252 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004253 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004254 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004255 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004256 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004257}
4258
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004259QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004260 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4261 return getDecayedType(T);
4262 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004263}
4264
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004265QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004266 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4267 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4268 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4269}
4270
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004271/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4272/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4273/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4274/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4275///
4276/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004277QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004278 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4279 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4280 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4281 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4282 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4283 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004284
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004285 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004286
4287 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004288 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004289}
4290
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004291QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4292 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004293}
4294
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004295QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4296 Qualifiers qs;
4297 while (true) {
4298 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004299 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004300 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004301
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004302 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004303 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004304 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004305
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004306 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004307}
4308
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004309/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004310uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004311ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4312 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4313 do {
4314 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004315 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4316 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004317 } while (CA);
4318 return ElementCount;
4319}
4320
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004321/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4322/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004323static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004324 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004325 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004326
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004327 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4328 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004329 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004330 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004331 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4332 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4333 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004334 }
4335}
4336
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004337/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4338/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004339/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4340/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004341QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4342 QualType Domain) const {
4343 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4344 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4345 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004346 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004347 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4348 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4349 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4350 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004351 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004352
4353 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4354 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004355 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004356 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4357 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4358 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004359 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004360 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004361}
4362
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004363/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4364/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4365/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004366/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004367int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004368 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4369 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004370
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004371 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004372 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004373 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004374 return 1;
4375 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004376}
4377
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004378/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4379/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4380/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004381unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004382 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004383
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004384 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004385 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004386 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004387 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004388 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4389 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4390 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4391 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004392 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004393 case BuiltinType::Short:
4394 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004395 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004396 case BuiltinType::Int:
4397 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004398 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004399 case BuiltinType::Long:
4400 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004401 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004402 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4403 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004404 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004405 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4406 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4407 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004408 }
4409}
4410
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004411/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4412/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4413///
4414/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4415/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004416QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004417 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4418 return QualType();
4419
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004420 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004421 if (!Field)
4422 return QualType();
4423
4424 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4425
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004426 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004427 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4428 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4429 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4430 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4431 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4432 return IntTy;
4433
4434 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4435 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4436
4437 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4438 // like the base type.
4439 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4440 // is ridiculous.
4441 return QualType();
4442}
4443
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004444/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4445/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4446/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004447QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004448 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4449 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004450 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4451 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004452
4453 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4454 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4455 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4456 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4457 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4458 // unsigned long long int [...]
4459 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4460 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4461 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4462 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4463 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4464 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4465 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4466 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4467 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4468 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4469 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4470 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4471 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4472 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4473 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4474 }
4475 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4476 }
4477 }
4478
4479 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004480 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4481 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004482 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4483 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004484 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4485 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4486}
4487
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004488/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4489/// type and returns its ownership.
4490Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4491 while (!T.isNull()) {
4492 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4493 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4494 if (T->isArrayType())
4495 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4496 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4497 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4498 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004499 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004500 else
4501 break;
4502 }
4503
4504 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4505}
4506
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004507static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4508 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4509 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4510 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4511 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004512 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004513}
4514
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004515/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004516/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004517/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004518int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004519 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4520 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004521
4522 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4523 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4524 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4525 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4526 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4527
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004528 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004529
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004530 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4531 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004532
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004533 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4534 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004536 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4537 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4538 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4539 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004540
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004541 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4542 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4543 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4544 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4545 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004546
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004547 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4548 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004549 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004550 return -1;
4551 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004552
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004553 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4554 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4555 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004556
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004557 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4558 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004559 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004560 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004561}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004562
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004563// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004564QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004565 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004566 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004567 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004568
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004569 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004570
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004571 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004572 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004573 // int flags;
4574 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004575 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004576 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004577 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004578 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4579
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004580 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004581 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004582 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004583 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004584 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4585 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4586 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004587 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004588 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004589 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004590 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004591 }
4592
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004593 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004594 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004595
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004596 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004597}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004598
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004599QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4600 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004601 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004602 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4603 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4604 }
4605 return ObjCSuperType;
4606}
4607
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004608void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004609 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004610 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4611 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4612}
4613
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004614QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004615 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4616 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4617
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004618 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004619 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004620 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4621 RD->startDefinition();
4622
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004623 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4624 UnsignedLongTy,
4625 UnsignedLongTy,
4626 };
4627
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004628 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004629 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004630 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004631 };
4632
4633 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004634 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4635 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004636 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4637 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004638 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004639 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004640 }
4641
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004642 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004643
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004644 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004645
4646 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4647}
4648
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004649QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004650 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4651 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4652
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004653 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004654 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004655 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4656 RD->startDefinition();
4657
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004658 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4659 UnsignedLongTy,
4660 UnsignedLongTy,
4661 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4662 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4663 };
4664
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004665 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004666 "reserved",
4667 "Size",
4668 "CopyFuncPtr",
4669 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4670 };
4671
4672 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004673 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4674 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004675 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4676 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004677 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004678 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004679 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004680 }
4681
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004682 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004683
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004684 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004685 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4686}
4687
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004688/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4689/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4690/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4691bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4692 const VarDecl *D) {
4693 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4694 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4695 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4696
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004697 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004698 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004699
4700 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4701
4702 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4703
4704 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4705 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4706 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4707
4708 switch (lifetime) {
4709 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4710
4711 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4712 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4713 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4714 return false;
4715
4716 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4717 // byref routines.
4718 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4719 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4720 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4721 return true;
4722 }
4723 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4724 }
4725 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4726 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004727}
4728
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004729bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4730 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4731 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4732
4733 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4734 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4735 return false;
4736
4737 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004738 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004739 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4740 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4741 }
4742 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4743 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4744 // MRR.
4745 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4746 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4747 else
4748 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4749 return true;
4750}
4751
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004752TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4753 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004754 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4755 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004756 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4757}
4758
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004759// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4760// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004761static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004762 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004763 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4764 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004765
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004766 return false;
4767}
4768
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004769/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004770/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004771CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004772 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4773 return CharUnits::Zero();
4774
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004775 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004776
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004777 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004778 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004779 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004780 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4781 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004782 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004783 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004784}
4785
4786static inline
4787std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4788 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004789}
4790
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004791/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004792/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004793std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4794 std::string S;
4795
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004796 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4797 QualType BlockTy =
4798 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4799 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004800 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004801 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4802 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4803 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004804 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004805 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004806 // Compute size of all parameters.
4807 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4808 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4809 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004810 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4811 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004812 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4813 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004814 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004815 if (sz.isZero())
4816 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004817 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004818 ParmOffset += sz;
4819 }
4820 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004821 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004822 // Block pointer and offset.
4823 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004824
4825 // Argument types.
4826 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004827 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004828 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4829 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4830 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4831 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4832 // elements.
4833 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4834 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4835 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4836 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004837 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004838 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4839 S, true /*Extended*/);
4840 else
4841 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004842 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004843 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004844 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004845
4846 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004847}
4848
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004849bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004850 std::string& S) {
4851 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004852 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004853 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4854 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004855 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4856 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004857 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004858 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004859 continue;
4860
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004861 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004862 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004863 ParmOffset += sz;
4864 }
4865 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4866 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4867
4868 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004869 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004870 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4871 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4872 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4873 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4874 // elements.
4875 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4876 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4877 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4878 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4879 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4880 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4881 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4882 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004883
4884 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004885}
4886
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004887/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4888/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4889/// block object types.
4890void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4891 QualType T, std::string& S,
4892 bool Extended) const {
4893 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4894 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4895 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004896 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004897 true /*OutermostType*/,
4898 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4899 false /*StructField*/,
4900 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4901 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4902}
4903
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004904/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004905/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004906bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004907 std::string& S,
4908 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004909 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004910 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004911 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4912 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004913 // Compute size of all parameters.
4914 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4915 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4916 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004917 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004918 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4919 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004920 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004921 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004922 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004923 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004924 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004925 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004926 continue;
4927
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004928 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4929 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004930 ParmOffset += sz;
4931 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004932 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004933 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004934 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004935
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004936 // Argument types.
4937 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004938 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004939 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004940 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004941 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004942 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004943 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4944 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4945 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004946 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004947 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4948 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4949 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004950 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4951 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004952 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004953 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004954 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004955
4956 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004957}
4958
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004959ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
4960ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
4961 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
4962 const Decl *Container) const {
4963 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004964 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004965 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
4966 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00004967 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
4968 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4969 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004970 } else {
4971 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
4972 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
4973 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4974 return PID;
4975 }
4976 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004977}
4978
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004979/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004980/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004981/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4982/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004983/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4984/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4985/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4986/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4987/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004988/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4989/// @code
4990/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4991/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4992/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4993/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4994/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4995/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4996/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4997/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00004998/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004999/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5000/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5001/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5002/// };
5003/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005004void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005005 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005006 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005007 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5008 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005009 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005010
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005011 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5012 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5013 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5014 Dynamic = true;
5015 else
5016 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005017 }
5018
5019 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5020 S = "T";
5021
5022 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005023 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5024 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005025 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005026
5027 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5028 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005029 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5030 S += ",C";
5031 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5032 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005033 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5034 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005035 } else {
5036 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5037 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5038 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005039 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005040 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005041 }
5042 }
5043
5044 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5045 // are "dynamic by default".
5046 if (Dynamic)
5047 S += ",D";
5048
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005049 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5050 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005051
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005052 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5053 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005054 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005055 }
5056
5057 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5058 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005059 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005060 }
5061
5062 if (SynthesizePID) {
5063 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5064 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005065 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005066 }
5067
5068 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5069}
5070
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005071/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005072/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5073/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005074/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5075///
5076void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005077 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005078 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005079 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005080 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005081 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005082 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005083 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5084 }
5085 }
5086}
5087
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005088void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005089 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005090 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5091 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5092 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5093 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005094 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005095 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005096}
5097
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005098void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5099 std::string& S) const {
5100 // Encode result type.
5101 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5102 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5103 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5104 true /* outermost type */,
5105 true /* encoding property */);
5106}
5107
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005108static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5109 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5110 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005111 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5112 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5113 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5114 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005115 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005116 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005117 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005118 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5119 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005120 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005121 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5122 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5123 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5124 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5125 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005126 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5127 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005128 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5129 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005130 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005131 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5132 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5133 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5134 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005135 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005136 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5137
5138 case BuiltinType::Half:
5139 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5140 return ' ';
5141
5142 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5143 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5144 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5145 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5146
5147 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5148 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5149 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5150 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5151 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5152 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5153 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005154 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005155 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005156 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5157#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5158#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5159 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5160#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5161 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005162 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005163 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005164}
5165
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005166static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5167 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5168
5169 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5170 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5171 return 'i';
5172
5173 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005174 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5175 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005176}
5177
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005178static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005179 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005180 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005181 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005182 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5183 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5184 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5185 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5186 //
5187 // struct
5188 // {
5189 // int integer;
5190 // int flags:2;
5191 // };
5192 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5193 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5194 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5195 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5196 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005197 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005198 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5199 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005200 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005201 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5202 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005203 else {
5204 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5205 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5206 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005207 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005208 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005209}
5210
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005211// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005212void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5213 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5214 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005215 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005216 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005217 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005218 bool StructField,
5219 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005220 bool EncodeClassNames,
5221 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005222 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5223 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5224 case Type::Builtin:
5225 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005226 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005227 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005228 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5229 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5230 else
5231 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005232 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005233
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005234 case Type::Complex: {
5235 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005236 S += 'j';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005237 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
5238 false, false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005239 return;
5240 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005241
5242 case Type::Atomic: {
5243 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5244 S += 'A';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005245 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005246 false, false);
5247 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005248 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005249
5250 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5251 case Type::Pointer:
5252 case Type::LValueReference:
5253 case Type::RValueReference: {
5254 QualType PointeeTy;
5255 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5256 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5257 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5258 S += ':';
5259 return;
5260 }
5261 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5262 } else {
5263 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5264 }
5265
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005266 bool isReadOnly = false;
5267 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5268 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5269 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005270 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005271 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005272 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5273 isReadOnly = true;
5274 S += 'r';
5275 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005276 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005277 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005278 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5279 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005280 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5281 isReadOnly = true;
5282 S += 'r';
5283 }
5284 }
5285 if (isReadOnly) {
5286 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5287 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5288 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005289 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005290 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005291 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005293 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5294 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5295 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005296 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005297 S += '*';
5298 return;
5299 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005300 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005301 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5302 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5303 S += '#';
5304 return;
5305 }
5306 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5307 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5308 S += '@';
5309 return;
5310 }
5311 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005312 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005313 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005314 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5315
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005316 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005317 nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005318 return;
5319 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005320
5321 case Type::ConstantArray:
5322 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5323 case Type::VariableArray: {
5324 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5325
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005326 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005327 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5328 S += '^';
5329
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005330 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005331 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5332 } else {
5333 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005334
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005335 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5336 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5337 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005338 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005339 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5340 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005341 S += '0';
5342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005343
5344 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005345 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5346 S += ']';
5347 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005348 return;
5349 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005350
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005351 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5352 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005353 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005354 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005355
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005356 case Type::Record: {
5357 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005358 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005359 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5360 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5361 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005362 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5363 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5364 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005365 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5366 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005367 TemplateArgs.data(),
5368 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005369 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005370 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005371 } else {
5372 S += '?';
5373 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005374 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005375 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005376 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5377 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5378 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005379 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005380 if (FD) {
5381 S += '"';
5382 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5383 S += '"';
5384 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005385
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005386 // Special case bit-fields.
5387 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5388 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005389 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005390 } else {
5391 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5392 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5393 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5394 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5395 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5396 /*StructField*/true);
5397 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005398 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005399 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005400 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005401 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005402 return;
5403 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005404
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005405 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5406 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005407 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005408 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005409 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005410
5411 S += '<';
5412 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005413 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5414 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5415 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5416 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005417 // Block self
5418 S += "@?";
5419 // Block parameters
5420 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005421 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5422 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5423 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5424 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5425 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005426 }
5427 S += '>';
5428 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005429 return;
5430 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005431
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005432 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5433 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5434 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5435 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5436 S += "{objc_object=}";
5437 return;
5438 }
5439 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5440 S += "{objc_class=}";
5441 return;
5442 }
5443 }
5444
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005445 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5446 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5447 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005448
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005449 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5450 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5451 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005452 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005453 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005454 S += '{';
5455 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5456 S += II->getName();
5457 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005458 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005459 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5460 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005461 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005462 if (Field->isBitField())
5463 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005464 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005465 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5466 false, false, false, false, false,
5467 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005468 }
5469 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005470 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005473 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5474 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005475 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5476 S += '@';
5477 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005480 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5481 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5482 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5483 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005484 S += '#';
5485 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005487
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005488 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005490 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5491 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005492 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005493 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5494 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005495 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005496 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005497 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005498 S += I->getNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005499 S += '>';
5500 }
5501 S += '"';
5502 }
5503 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005504 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005505
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005506 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5507 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005508 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5509 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005510 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005511 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005512 // {...};
5513 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005514 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005515 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005516 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5517 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5518 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5519 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5520 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5521 S += '{';
5522 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5523 S += '}';
5524 return;
5525 }
5526 }
5527 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005528 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5529 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005530 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005531 false, false, false, false, false,
5532 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005533 return;
5534 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005535
5536 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005537 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5538 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005539 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005540 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005541 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005542 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005543 S += I->getNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005544 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005545 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005546 S += '"';
5547 }
5548 return;
5549 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005550
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005551 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005552 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5553 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005554 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005555
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005556 case Type::Vector:
5557 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005558 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5559 // insufficient.
5560 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5561 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005562
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005563 case Type::Auto:
5564 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5565 // Just ignore it.
5566 return;
5567
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005568#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5569#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5570#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5571 case Type::KIND:
5572#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5573 case Type::KIND:
5574#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5575 case Type::KIND:
5576#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5577 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005578 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005579 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005580}
5581
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005582void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5583 std::string &S,
5584 const FieldDecl *FD,
5585 bool includeVBases) const {
5586 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5587 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5588 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5589 return;
5590
5591 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5592 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5593 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5594
5595 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005596 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5597 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5598 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005599 if (base->isEmpty())
5600 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005601 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005602 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5603 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5604 }
5605 }
5606 }
5607
5608 unsigned i = 0;
5609 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5610 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5611 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5612 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5613 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005614 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005615 }
5616
5617 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005618 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5619 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005620 if (base->isEmpty())
5621 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005622 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005623 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5624 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005625 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5626 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005627 }
5628 }
5629
5630 CharUnits size;
5631 if (CXXRec) {
5632 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5633 } else {
5634 size = layout.getSize();
5635 }
5636
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005637#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005638 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005639#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005640 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5641 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5642
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005643 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5644 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005645 if (FD) {
5646 S += "\"_vptr$";
5647 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5648 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5649 S += recname;
5650 S += '"';
5651 }
5652 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005653#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005654 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005655#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005656 }
5657
5658 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5659 // Mark the end of the structure.
5660 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5661 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005662 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005663 }
5664
5665 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005666#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005667 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005668 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5669 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5670 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5671 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5672 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5673 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5674 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5675 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5676 // longer then though.
5677 CurOffs += padding;
5678 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005679#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005680
5681 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005682 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005683 break; // reached end of structure.
5684
5685 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5686 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5687 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5688 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5689 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5690 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005691 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005692#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005693 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005694#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005695 } else {
5696 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5697 if (FD) {
5698 S += '"';
5699 S += field->getNameAsString();
5700 S += '"';
5701 }
5702
5703 if (field->isBitField()) {
5704 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005705#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005706 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005707#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005708 } else {
5709 QualType qt = field->getType();
5710 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5711 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5712 /*OutermostType*/false,
5713 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5714 /*StructField*/true);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005715#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005716 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005717#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005718 }
5719 }
5720 }
5721}
5722
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005723void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005724 std::string& S) const {
5725 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5726 S += 'n';
5727 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5728 S += 'N';
5729 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5730 S += 'o';
5731 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5732 S += 'O';
5733 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5734 S += 'R';
5735 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5736 S += 'V';
5737}
5738
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005739TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5740 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005741 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005742 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005743 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005744 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005745 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005746}
5747
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005748TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5749 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005750 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5751 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005752 }
5753 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005754}
5755
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005756TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5757 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005758 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005759 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005760 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005761 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005762 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005763}
5764
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005765ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5766 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5767 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5768 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5769 SourceLocation(),
5770 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005771 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005772 SourceLocation(), true);
5773 }
5774
5775 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5776}
5777
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005778//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5779// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5780//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5781
5782static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5783 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005784 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5785 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005786}
5787
5788static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5789 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005790 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5791 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005792}
5793
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005794static TypedefDecl *
5795CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005796 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005797 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005798 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5799 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5800 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5801 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5802 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005803 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005804 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005805 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005806 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005807 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005808 }
5809
5810 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5811
5812 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5813 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5814 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5815
5816 // void *__stack;
5817 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5818 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5819
5820 // void *__gr_top;
5821 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5822 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5823
5824 // void *__vr_top;
5825 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5826 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5827
5828 // int __gr_offs;
5829 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5830 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5831
5832 // int __vr_offs;
5833 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5834 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5835
5836 // Create fields
5837 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5838 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5839 VaListTagDecl,
5840 SourceLocation(),
5841 SourceLocation(),
5842 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005843 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5844 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005845 /*Mutable=*/false,
5846 ICIS_NoInit);
5847 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5848 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5849 }
5850 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5851 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5852 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5853
5854 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005855 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005856}
5857
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005858static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5859 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5860 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5861
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005862 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005863 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5864
5865 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5866 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5867 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5868
5869 // unsigned char gpr;
5870 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5871 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5872
5873 // unsigned char fpr;
5874 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5875 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5876
5877 // unsigned short reserved;
5878 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5879 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5880
5881 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5882 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5883 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5884
5885 // void* reg_save_area;
5886 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5887 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5888
5889 // Create fields
5890 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5891 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5892 SourceLocation(),
5893 SourceLocation(),
5894 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005895 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5896 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005897 /*Mutable=*/false,
5898 ICIS_NoInit);
5899 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5900 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5901 }
5902 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5903 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005904 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005905
5906 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005907 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5908 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5909
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005910 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5911 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5912
5913 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5914 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5915 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5916 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5917 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005918 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005919}
5920
5921static TypedefDecl *
5922CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5923 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5924 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005925 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005926 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5927
5928 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5929 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5930 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5931
5932 // unsigned gp_offset;
5933 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5934 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5935
5936 // unsigned fp_offset;
5937 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5938 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5939
5940 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5941 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5942 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5943
5944 // void* reg_save_area;
5945 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5946 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5947
5948 // Create fields
5949 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5950 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5951 VaListTagDecl,
5952 SourceLocation(),
5953 SourceLocation(),
5954 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005955 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5956 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005957 /*Mutable=*/false,
5958 ICIS_NoInit);
5959 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5960 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5961 }
5962 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5963 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005964 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005965
5966 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005967 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5968 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5969
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005970 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5971 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5972
5973 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5974 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5975 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5976 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5977 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005978 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005979}
5980
5981static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5982 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5983 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5984 QualType IntArrayType
5985 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5986 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005987 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005988}
5989
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005990static TypedefDecl *
5991CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005992 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005993 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005994 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5995 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5996 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5997 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5998 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5999 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6000 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006001 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006002 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006003 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006004 }
6005
6006 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6007
6008 // void * __ap;
6009 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6010 VaListDecl,
6011 SourceLocation(),
6012 SourceLocation(),
6013 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6014 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006015 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6016 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006017 /*Mutable=*/false,
6018 ICIS_NoInit);
6019 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6020 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6021
6022 // };
6023 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6024
6025 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006026 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6027 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006028}
6029
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006030static TypedefDecl *
6031CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6032 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6033 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006034 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006035 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6036
6037 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6038 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6039 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6040
6041 // long __gpr;
6042 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6043 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6044
6045 // long __fpr;
6046 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6047 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6048
6049 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6050 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6051 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6052
6053 // void *__reg_save_area;
6054 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6055 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6056
6057 // Create fields
6058 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6059 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6060 VaListTagDecl,
6061 SourceLocation(),
6062 SourceLocation(),
6063 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006064 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6065 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006066 /*Mutable=*/false,
6067 ICIS_NoInit);
6068 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6069 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6070 }
6071 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6072 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6073 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6074
6075 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006076 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6077 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006078 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6079 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6080
6081 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6082 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6083 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6084 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6085 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006086
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006087 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006088}
6089
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006090static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6091 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6092 switch (Kind) {
6093 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6094 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6095 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6096 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006097 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6098 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006099 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6100 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6101 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6102 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6103 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6104 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006105 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6106 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006107 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6108 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006109 }
6110
6111 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6112}
6113
6114TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006115 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006116 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006117 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6118 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006119
6120 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6121}
6122
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006123QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6124 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6125 // declaration.
6126 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6127 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6128
6129 return VaListTagTy;
6130}
6131
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006132void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006133 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006134 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006135
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006136 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006137}
6138
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006139/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6140/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006141TemplateName
6142ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6143 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006144 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6145 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6146
6147 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6148 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6149 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6150
6151 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006152 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006153 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6154 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6155 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6156 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6157 *Storage++ = D;
6158 }
6159
6160 return TemplateName(OT);
6161}
6162
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006163/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6164/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006165TemplateName
6166ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6167 bool TemplateKeyword,
6168 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006169 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6170
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006171 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006172 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6173 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6174
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006175 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006176 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6177 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6178 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006179 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6180 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006181 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6182 }
6183
6184 return TemplateName(QTN);
6185}
6186
6187/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6188/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006189TemplateName
6190ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6191 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006192 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006193 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006194
6195 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6196 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6197
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006198 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006199 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6200 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6201
6202 if (QTN)
6203 return TemplateName(QTN);
6204
6205 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6206 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006207 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6208 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006209 } else {
6210 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006211 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6212 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006213 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6214 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6215 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6216 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006217 }
6218
6219 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6220 return TemplateName(QTN);
6221}
6222
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006223/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6224/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6225TemplateName
6226ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006227 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006228 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6229 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6230
6231 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6232 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006233
6234 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006235 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6236 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006237
6238 if (QTN)
6239 return TemplateName(QTN);
6240
6241 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6242 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006243 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6244 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006245 } else {
6246 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006247 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6248 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006249
6250 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6251 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6252 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6253 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006254 }
6255
6256 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6257 return TemplateName(QTN);
6258}
6259
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006260TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006261ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6262 TemplateName replacement) const {
6263 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6264 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006265
6266 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006267 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6268 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6269
6270 if (!subst) {
6271 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6272 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6273 }
6274
6275 return TemplateName(subst);
6276}
6277
6278TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006279ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6280 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6281 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6282 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6283 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006284
6285 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006286 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6287 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6288
6289 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006290 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006291 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6292 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6293 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6294 }
6295
6296 return TemplateName(Subst);
6297}
6298
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006299/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006300/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6301/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006302CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006303 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006304 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006305 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6306 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006307 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6308 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6309 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6310 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6311 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6312 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6313 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6314 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6315 }
6316
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006317 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006318}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006319
6320//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6321// Type Predicates.
6322//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6323
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006324/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6325/// garbage collection attribute.
6326///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006327Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006328 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006329 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6330
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006331 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006332 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6333
6334 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6335 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6336 // as __strong.
6337 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6338 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6339 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6340 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6341 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6342 } else {
6343 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6344 // pointer.
6345#ifndef NDEBUG
6346 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6347 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6348 CT = AT->getElementType();
6349 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6350#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006351 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006352 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006353}
6354
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006355//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6356// Type Compatibility Testing
6357//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006358
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006359/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006360/// compatible.
6361static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6362 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006363 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006364 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006365 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006366}
6367
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006368bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6369 QualType SecondVec) {
6370 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6371 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6372
6373 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6374 return true;
6375
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006376 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6377 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006378 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6379 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006380 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006381 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006382 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6383 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6384 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6385 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006386 return true;
6387
6388 return false;
6389}
6390
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006391//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6392// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6393//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6394
6395/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6396/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006397bool
6398ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6399 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006400 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006401 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006402 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6403 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006404 return true;
6405 return false;
6406}
6407
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006408/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6409/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006410bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6411 QualType rhs) {
6412 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6413 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6414 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6415
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006416 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006417 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006418 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006419 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6420 match = true;
6421 break;
6422 }
6423 }
6424 if (!match)
6425 return false;
6426 }
6427 return true;
6428}
6429
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006430/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6431/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6432bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6433 bool compare) {
6434 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006435 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006436 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6437 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006438 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006439 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6440 return true;
6441
6442 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006443 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006444
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006445 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006446
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006447 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006448 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006449 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6450 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006451 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006452 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6453 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6454 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006455 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006456 return false;
6457 }
6458 }
6459 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6460 return true;
6461 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006462 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006463 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006464 bool match = false;
6465
6466 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6467 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6468 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006469 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006470 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6471 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6472 match = true;
6473 break;
6474 }
6475 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006476 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006477 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6478 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006479 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006480 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6481 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6482 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006483 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006484 match = true;
6485 break;
6486 }
6487 }
6488 }
6489 if (!match)
6490 return false;
6491 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006492
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006493 return true;
6494 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006495
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006496 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6497 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6498
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006499 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006500 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006501 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006502 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006503 bool match = false;
6504
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006505 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006506 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6507 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006508 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6509 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006510 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006511 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6512 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6513 match = true;
6514 break;
6515 }
6516 }
6517 if (!match)
6518 return false;
6519 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006520
6521 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6522 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6523 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6524 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6525 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6526 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6527 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6528 // assume that it is mismatch.
6529 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6530 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006531 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006532 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006533 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006534 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6535 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6536 match = true;
6537 break;
6538 }
6539 }
6540 if (!match)
6541 return false;
6542 }
6543 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006544 return true;
6545 }
6546 return false;
6547}
6548
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006549/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006550/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6551/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6552///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006553bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6554 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006555 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6556 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6557
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006558 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006559 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6560 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006561 return true;
6562
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006563 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006564 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6565 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006566 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006567
6568 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6569 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6570 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6571
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006572 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6573 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006574 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006575
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006576 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006577}
6578
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006579/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006580/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006581/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6582/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6583/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6584bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6585 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006586 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6587 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006588 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006589 return true;
6590
6591 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6592 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6593 }
6594
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006595 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006596 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6597 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6598 false);
6599
6600 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6601 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6602 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6603 if (LHS != RHS) {
6604 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006605 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006606 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006607 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006608 }
6609 else
6610 return true;
6611 }
6612 return false;
6613}
6614
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006615/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6616/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6617/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6618/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6619static
6620void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6621 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6622 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006623 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006624
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006625 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6626 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6627 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6628 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006629
6630 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6631 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6632 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6633 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6634 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006635 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006636 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6637 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006638 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6639 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6640 }
6641
6642 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6643 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006644 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6645 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006646 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6647 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6648 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006649 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006650 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006651 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6652 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006653 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6654 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6655 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6656 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6657 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006658 }
6659}
6660
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006661/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6662/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6663/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6664/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6665QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006666 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6667 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6668 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6669 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6670 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6671 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006672 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006673 return QualType();
6674
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006675 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006676 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006677 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006678 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006679 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6680
6681 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6682 if (!Protocols.empty())
6683 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6684 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6685 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006686 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006687 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006688
6689 return QualType();
6690}
6691
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006692bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6693 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6694 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6695 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6696
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006697 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6698 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006699 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006700 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006701
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006702 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6703 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006704 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006705 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006706
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006707 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6708 // more detailed analysis is required.
6709 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6710 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6711 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6712 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006713 bool IsSuperClass =
6714 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6715 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006716 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6717 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6718 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6719 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6720 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006721 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006722 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6723 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6724 return false;
6725
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006726 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6727 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6728 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006729 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6730 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6731 break;
6732 }
6733 }
6734 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6735 return false;
6736 }
6737 return true;
6738 }
6739 return false;
6740 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006741
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006742 for (const auto *LHSPI : LHS->quals()) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006743 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6744
6745 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6746 // are incompatible.
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006747 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) {
6748 if (RHSPI->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSPI->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006749 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006750 break;
6751 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006752 }
6753 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6754 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6755 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006756 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006757 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6758 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006759}
6760
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006761bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6762 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006763 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6764 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006765
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006766 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006767 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006768
6769 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6770 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006771}
6772
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006773bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6774 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6775 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6776 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6777}
6778
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006779/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006780/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006781/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006782/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006783bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6784 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006785 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006786 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6787
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006788 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006789}
6790
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006791bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006792 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006793}
6794
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006795bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6796 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6797}
6798
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006799/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6800/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6801/// QualType()
6802QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6803 bool OfBlockPointer,
6804 bool Unqualified) {
6805 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6806 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6807 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006808 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6809 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006810 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6811 if (!MT.isNull())
6812 return MT;
6813 }
6814 }
6815 }
6816
6817 return QualType();
6818}
6819
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006820/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6821/// parameter types
6822QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6823 bool OfBlockPointer,
6824 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006825 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6826 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6827 // type is compatible with a union member
6828 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6829 Unqualified);
6830 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6831 return lmerge;
6832
6833 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6834 Unqualified);
6835 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6836 return rmerge;
6837
6838 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6839}
6840
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006841QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006842 bool OfBlockPointer,
6843 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006844 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6845 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006846 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6847 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006848 bool allLTypes = true;
6849 bool allRTypes = true;
6850
6851 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006852 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006853 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006854 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6855 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006856 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6857 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6858 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006859 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006860 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006861 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006862 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006863 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006864 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006865
6866 if (Unqualified)
6867 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6868
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006869 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6870 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006871 if (Unqualified) {
6872 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6873 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6874 }
6875
6876 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006877 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006878 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006879 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006880
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006881 // FIXME: double check this
6882 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6883 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6884 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006885 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6886 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006887
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006888 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006889 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006890 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006891
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006892 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006893 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6894 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006895 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6896 return QualType();
6897
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006898 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6899 return QualType();
6900
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006901 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6902 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006903
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006904 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6905 allLTypes = false;
6906 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6907 allRTypes = false;
6908
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006909 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006910
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006911 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006912 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6913 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006914 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6915 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006916 return QualType();
6917
6918 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6919 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6920 return QualType();
6921
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006922 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6923 return QualType();
6924
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006925 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6926 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6927 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006928
6929 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006930 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006931 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
6932 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6933 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6934 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
6935 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6936 if (paramType.isNull())
6937 return QualType();
6938
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006939 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006940 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
6941
6942 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006943 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006944 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
6945 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006946 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006947
6948 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006949 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006950 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006951 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006952 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006953
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006954 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6955 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006956
6957 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6958 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006959 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006960 }
6961
6962 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6963 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6964
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006965 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006966 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006967 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006968 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
6969 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
6970 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
6971 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
6972 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
6973 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006974 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
6975 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006976
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006977 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00006978 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006979 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
6980 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6981 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006982 return QualType();
6983 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006984
6985 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
6986 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006987 return QualType();
6988 }
6989
6990 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6991 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006992
6993 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
6994 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006995 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006996 }
6997
6998 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6999 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007000 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007001}
7002
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007003/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7004static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7005 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7006 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7007 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7008 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7009 // type.
7010 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7011 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7012 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7013 return other;
7014
7015 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7016 // integral type of the same size.
7017 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7018 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7019 return other;
7020
7021 return QualType();
7022}
7023
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007024QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007025 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007026 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007027 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7028 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7029 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007030 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7031 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007032 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7033 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007034
7035 if (Unqualified) {
7036 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7037 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7038 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007039
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007040 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7041 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7042
7043 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7044 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7045 return LHS;
7046
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007047 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007048 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7049 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007050 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7051 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7052 // mismatch.
7053 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007054 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7055 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007056 return QualType();
7057
7058 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7059 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7060 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7061 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7062 // qualified __strong.
7063 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7064 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7065 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7066
7067 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7068 return QualType();
7069
7070 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7071 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7072 }
7073 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7074 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7075 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007076 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007077 }
7078
7079 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007080
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007081 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7082 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007083
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007084 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7085 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7086 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7087 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007088
7089 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007090 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7091 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7092 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7093 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007094
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007095 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7096 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7097 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7098
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007099 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7100 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7101 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007102
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007103 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007104 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007105 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7106 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007107 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007108 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007109 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007110 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007111 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007112 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007113 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007114 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7115 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7116 return LHS;
7117 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7118 return RHS;
7119 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007120
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007121 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007122 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007123
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007124 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007125 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007126#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7127#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007128#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007129#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7130#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7131#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007132 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007133
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007134 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007135 case Type::LValueReference:
7136 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007137 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007138 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007139
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007140 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007141 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7142 case Type::VariableArray:
7143 case Type::FunctionProto:
7144 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007145 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007146
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007147 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007148 {
7149 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007150 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7151 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007152 if (Unqualified) {
7153 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7154 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7155 }
7156 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7157 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007158 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007159 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007160 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007161 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007162 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007163 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7164 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007165 case Type::BlockPointer:
7166 {
7167 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007168 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7169 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007170 if (Unqualified) {
7171 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7172 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7173 }
7174 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7175 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007176 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7177 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7178 return LHS;
7179 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7180 return RHS;
7181 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7182 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007183 case Type::Atomic:
7184 {
7185 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7186 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7187 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7188 if (Unqualified) {
7189 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7190 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7191 }
7192 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7193 Unqualified);
7194 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7195 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7196 return LHS;
7197 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7198 return RHS;
7199 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7200 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007201 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007202 {
7203 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7204 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7205 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7206 return QualType();
7207
7208 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7209 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007210 if (Unqualified) {
7211 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7212 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7213 }
7214
7215 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007216 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007217 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7218 return LHS;
7219 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7220 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007221 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7222 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7223 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7224 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007225 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7226 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007227 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7228 return LHS;
7229 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7230 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007231 if (LVAT) {
7232 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7233 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7234 // has to be different.
7235 return LHS;
7236 }
7237 if (RVAT) {
7238 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7239 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7240 // has to be different.
7241 return RHS;
7242 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007243 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7244 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007245 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7246 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007247 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007248 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007249 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007250 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007251 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007252 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007253 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007254 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007255 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007256 case Type::Complex:
7257 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7258 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007259 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007260 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007261 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7262 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007263 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007264 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007265 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7266 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007267 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7268 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007269 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7270 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7271 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007272 return LHS;
7273
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007274 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007275 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007276 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007277 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7278 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7279 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007280 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7281 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007282 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007283 return QualType();
7284 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007285 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7286 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007287 return LHS;
7288
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007289 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007290 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007291 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007292
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007293 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007294}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007295
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007296bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7297 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7298 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007299 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7300 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007301 return false;
7302 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7303 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7304 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7305 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007306 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007307 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7308 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007309 return false;
7310 }
7311 return true;
7312}
7313
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007314/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7315/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7316/// return types.
7317QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7318 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7319 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7320 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7321 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7322 return LHS;
7323 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7324 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7325 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007326 QualType OldReturnType =
7327 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007328 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007329 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007330 QualType ResReturnType =
7331 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7332 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7333 return QualType();
7334 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7335 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7336 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7337 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7338 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007339 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7340 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007341 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007342 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007343 return ResultType;
7344 }
7345 }
7346 return QualType();
7347 }
7348
7349 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7350 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7351 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7352 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7353 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7354 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7355 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7356 return QualType();
7357
7358 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7359 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7360 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7361 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7362 // qualified __strong.
7363 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7364 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7365 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7366
7367 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7368 return QualType();
7369
7370 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7371 return LHS;
7372 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7373 return RHS;
7374 return QualType();
7375 }
7376
7377 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7378 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7379 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7380 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7381 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7382 return LHS;
7383 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7384 return RHS;
7385 }
7386 return QualType();
7387}
7388
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007389//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007390// Integer Predicates
7391//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007392
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007393unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007394 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007395 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007396 if (T->isBooleanType())
7397 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007398 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007399 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7400}
7401
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007402QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007403 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007404
7405 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7406 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7407 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007408 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007409
7410 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7411 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007412 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007413
7414 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7415 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007416 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7417 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7418 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7419 return UnsignedCharTy;
7420 case BuiltinType::Short:
7421 return UnsignedShortTy;
7422 case BuiltinType::Int:
7423 return UnsignedIntTy;
7424 case BuiltinType::Long:
7425 return UnsignedLongTy;
7426 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7427 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007428 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7429 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007430 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007431 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007432 }
7433}
7434
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007435ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7436
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007437void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7438 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007439
7440//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7441// Builtin Type Computation
7442//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7443
7444/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007445/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7446/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7447/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7448/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007449///
7450/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7451/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007452static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007453 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007454 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007455 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007456 // Modifiers.
7457 int HowLong = 0;
7458 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007459 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007460
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007461 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007462 bool Done = false;
7463 while (!Done) {
7464 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007465 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007466 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007467 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007468 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007469 case 'S':
7470 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7471 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7472 Signed = true;
7473 break;
7474 case 'U':
7475 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7476 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7477 Unsigned = true;
7478 break;
7479 case 'L':
7480 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7481 ++HowLong;
7482 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007483 case 'W':
7484 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7485 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7486 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7487 default:
7488 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7489 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7490 HowLong = 1;
7491 break;
7492 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7493 HowLong = 2;
7494 break;
7495 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007496 }
7497 }
7498
7499 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007500
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007501 // Read the base type.
7502 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007503 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007504 case 'v':
7505 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7506 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7507 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7508 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007509 case 'h':
7510 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7511 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7512 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7513 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007514 case 'f':
7515 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7516 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7517 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7518 break;
7519 case 'd':
7520 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7521 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7522 if (HowLong)
7523 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7524 else
7525 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7526 break;
7527 case 's':
7528 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7529 if (Unsigned)
7530 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7531 else
7532 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7533 break;
7534 case 'i':
7535 if (HowLong == 3)
7536 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7537 else if (HowLong == 2)
7538 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7539 else if (HowLong == 1)
7540 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7541 else
7542 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7543 break;
7544 case 'c':
7545 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7546 if (Signed)
7547 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7548 else if (Unsigned)
7549 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7550 else
7551 Type = Context.CharTy;
7552 break;
7553 case 'b': // boolean
7554 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7555 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7556 break;
7557 case 'z': // size_t.
7558 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7559 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7560 break;
7561 case 'F':
7562 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7563 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007564 case 'G':
7565 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7566 break;
7567 case 'H':
7568 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7569 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007570 case 'M':
7571 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7572 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007573 case 'a':
7574 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7575 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7576 break;
7577 case 'A':
7578 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7579 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7580 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7581 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7582 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7583 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7584 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7585 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7586 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7587 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007588 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007589 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007590 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007591 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007592 break;
7593 case 'V': {
7594 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007595 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7596 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007597 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007598
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007599 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7600 RequiresICE, false);
7601 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007602
7603 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007604 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007605 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007606 break;
7607 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007608 case 'E': {
7609 char *End;
7610
7611 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7612 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7613
7614 Str = End;
7615
7616 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7617 false);
7618 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7619 break;
7620 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007621 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007622 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7623 false);
7624 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007625 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7626 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007627 }
7628 case 'Y' : {
7629 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7630 break;
7631 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007632 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007633 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7634 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007635 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007636 return QualType();
7637 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007638 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007639 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007640 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007641 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007642 else
7643 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7644
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007645 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007646 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007647 return QualType();
7648 }
7649 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007650 case 'K':
7651 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7652 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7653
7654 if (Type.isNull()) {
7655 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7656 return QualType();
7657 }
7658 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007659 case 'p':
7660 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7661 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007662 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007663
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007664 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7665 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007666 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007667 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007668 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7669 case '*':
7670 case '&': {
7671 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7672 // qualified with an address space.
7673 char *End;
7674 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7675 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7676 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7677 Str = End;
7678 }
7679 if (c == '*')
7680 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7681 else
7682 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7683 break;
7684 }
7685 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7686 case 'C':
7687 Type = Type.withConst();
7688 break;
7689 case 'D':
7690 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7691 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007692 case 'R':
7693 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7694 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007695 }
7696 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007697
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007698 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007699 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007700
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007701 return Type;
7702}
7703
7704/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007705QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007706 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007707 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007708 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007709
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007710 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007711
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007712 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007713 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007714 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7715 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007716 if (Error != GE_None)
7717 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007718
7719 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7720
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007721 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007722 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007723 if (Error != GE_None)
7724 return QualType();
7725
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007726 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7727 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7728 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7729 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7730
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007731 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7732 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7733 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007734
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007735 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7736 }
7737
7738 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7739 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7740
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007741 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007742 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7743
7744 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7745
7746 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7747 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7748 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007749
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007750 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007751 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7752 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007753
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007754 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007755}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007756
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007757static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7758 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007759 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007760 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007761
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007762 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7763 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7764 case TSK_Undeclared:
7765 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7766 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7767 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007768
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007769 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007770 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007771
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007772 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7773 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7774 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7775 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7776 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7777 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007778 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007779 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7780
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007781 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007782 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007783 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007784 }
7785
7786 if (!FD->isInlined())
7787 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007788
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007789 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7790 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007791 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007792 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7793
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007794 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7795 // externally visible.
7796 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7797 return External;
7798
7799 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007800 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007801 }
7802
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007803 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7804 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7805 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7806 if (FD->getMostRecentDecl()->isMSExternInline())
7807 return GVA_StrongODR;
7808
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007809 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007810}
7811
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007812static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7813 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7814 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7815 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7816 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7817 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7818 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7819 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7820 return GVA_StrongODR;
7821 }
7822 return L;
7823}
7824
7825GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7826 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7827 FD);
7828}
7829
7830static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7831 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007832 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7833 return GVA_Internal;
7834
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007835 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7836 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7837 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7838 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7839 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7840
7841 // Let the static local variable inherit it's linkage from the nearest
7842 // enclosing function.
7843 if (LexicalContext)
7844 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007845 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007846
7847 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7848 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7849 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7850 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7851 : StaticLocalLinkage;
7852 }
7853
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007854 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007855 case TSK_Undeclared:
7856 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7857 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007858
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007859 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007860 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007861
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007862 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7863 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7864
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007865 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007866 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007867 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007868
7869 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007870}
7871
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007872GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7873 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
7874 VD);
7875}
7876
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007877bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007878 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7879 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7880 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00007881 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
7882 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
7883 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007884 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7885 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7886 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7887 return false;
7888 } else
7889 return false;
7890
7891 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7892 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007893 return false;
7894
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007895 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7896 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7897 return false;
7898
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007899 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7900 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7901 return true;
7902
7903 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7904 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007905 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007906 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007907
7908 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7909 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7910 return true;
7911
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007912 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7913 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7914 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7915 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7916 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7917 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7918 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7919 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7920 return true;
7921 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007922 }
7923 }
7924
7925 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7926
7927 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7928 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7929 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007930 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
7931 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007932 return false;
7933 return true;
7934 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007935
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007936 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7937 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7938
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007939 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
7940 return false;
7941
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007942 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007943 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007944 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
7945 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007946 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007947
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007948 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7949 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7950 return true;
7951
7952 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7953 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7954 return true;
7955
7956 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007957}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007958
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007959CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
7960 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007961 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007962 if (IsCXXMethod)
7963 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007964
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007965 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007966}
7967
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007968bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007969 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7970 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7971}
7972
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00007973VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
7974 if (!VTContext.get()) {
7975 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
7976 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
7977 else
7978 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
7979 }
7980 return VTContext.get();
7981}
7982
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007983MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007984 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007985 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007986 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
7987 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
7988 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00007989 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007990 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007991 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007992 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007993 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007994 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007995}
7996
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007997CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007998
7999size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008000 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8001 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8002 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8003 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8004 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8005 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8006 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8007 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8008 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8009 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8010 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8011 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8012 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8013 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008014}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008015
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008016/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8017/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8018/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8019/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8020QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8021 unsigned Signed) const {
8022 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8023 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8024 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8025 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8026 return QualTy;
8027}
8028
8029/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8030/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8031/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8032QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8033 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8034 switch (Ty) {
8035 case TargetInfo::Float:
8036 return FloatTy;
8037 case TargetInfo::Double:
8038 return DoubleTy;
8039 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8040 return LongDoubleTy;
8041 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8042 return QualType();
8043 }
8044
8045 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8046}
8047
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008048void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8049 if (Number > 1)
8050 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008051}
8052
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008053unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8054 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8055 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8056 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008057}
8058
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008059void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8060 if (Number > 1)
8061 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8062}
8063
8064unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8065 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8066 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8067 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8068}
8069
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008070MangleNumberingContext &
8071ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008072 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8073 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8074 if (!MCtx)
8075 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8076 return *MCtx;
8077}
8078
8079MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8080 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008081}
8082
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008083void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8084 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8085}
8086
8087unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8088 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8089 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8090 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8091 return I->second;
8092}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008093
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008094APValue *
8095ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8096 bool MayCreate) {
8097 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8098 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8099 if (MayCreate)
8100 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8101
8102 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8103 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008104 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008105}
8106
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008107bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8108 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8109 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8110 return false;
8111
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008112 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8113 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8114 return false;
8115
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008116 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8117 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8118 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8119 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8120 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8121 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8122 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8123}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008124
8125namespace {
8126
8127 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8128 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8129 ///
8130 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8131 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8132 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8133 ///
8134 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8135 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8136
8137 public:
8138 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8139 ///
8140 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8141 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8142 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8143 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8144 return Visitor.Parents;
8145 }
8146
8147 private:
8148 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8149
8150 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8151 }
8152
8153 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8154 return true;
8155 }
8156 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8157 return true;
8158 }
8159 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8160 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8161 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8162 return false;
8163 }
8164
8165 template <typename T>
8166 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008167 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008168 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008169 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008170 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8171 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8172 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8173 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8174 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8175 // new matches.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008176 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8177 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8178 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8179 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008180 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8181 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8182 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008183 } else {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008184 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8185 auto *Node =
8186 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8187 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8188 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8189 delete Node;
8190 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008191 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008192
8193 auto *Vector =
8194 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8195 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8196 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8197 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8198 // types.
8199 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8200 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8201 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8202 if (!Found)
8203 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008204 }
8205 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008206 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8207 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8208 ParentStack.pop_back();
8209 return Result;
8210 }
8211
8212 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8213 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8214 }
8215
8216 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8217 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8218 }
8219
8220 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8221 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8222
8223 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8224 };
8225
8226} // end namespace
8227
8228ASTContext::ParentVector
8229ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8230 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8231 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8232 "used in the parent map.");
8233 if (!AllParents) {
8234 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8235 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8236 AllParents.reset(
8237 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8238 }
8239 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8240 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8241 return ParentVector();
8242 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008243 if (I->second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8244 return ParentVector(1, *I->second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>());
8245 }
8246 const auto &Parents = *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8247 return ParentVector(Parents.begin(), Parents.end());
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008248}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008249
8250bool
8251ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8252 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8253 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8254 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8255 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8256 return false;
8257 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8258 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8259 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008260 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008261 return false;
8262
8263 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8264 return false;
8265
8266 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8267 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8268 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8269 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8270 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8271 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8272 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8273 return false;
8274 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8275 return false;
8276 }
8277 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8278
8279}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008280
8281// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8282// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8283template
8284clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8285 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8286clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8287 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8288 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);